blob: 9d8fe9c85f0ee308095459575f6830d052176d9e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000499/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
500/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
501/// is Record.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000502static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
503 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000504 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000505 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000506
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000507 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
508 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
509 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000510 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000511 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000512 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000513 D != DEnd; ++D) {
514 if (*D == Record) {
515 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
516 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
517 ++D;
518 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor6e6ad602009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000519 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000520 return *D;
521 }
522 }
523
524 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
525 return 0;
526}
527
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000528/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
529/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
530/// actual member.
531///
532/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
533/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
534/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
535/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
536/// we found.
537///
538/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
539/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
540/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
541VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
542 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000543 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
544 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
545 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
546
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000547 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
549 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
550 do {
551 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000552 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000554 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000555 else {
556 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
557 break;
558 }
559 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000560 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000562
563 return BaseObject;
564}
565
566Sema::OwningExprResult
567Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
568 FieldDecl *Field,
569 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
570 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
571 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000572 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000573 AnonFields);
574
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
576 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
577 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
578 // found via name lookup.
579 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000580 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000581 if (BaseObject) {
582 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
583 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000584 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000585 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000586 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000587 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000588 BaseQuals
589 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
591 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
592 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
593 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
594 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000595 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
597 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
598 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000599 BaseQuals
600 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 } else {
602 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
603 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
604 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000605 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
606 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000607 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000608 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 = Context.getTagDeclType(
610 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
611 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000612 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
614 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
615 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000616 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000617 MD->getThisType(Context),
618 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
620 }
621 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000622 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
623 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000624 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000625 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000626 }
627
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000628 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000629 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
630 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000631 }
632
633 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
634 // anonymous struct/union.
635 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
638 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
639 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
640 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000641 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
642 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
643
644 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
645 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
646 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
647 ResultQuals.removeConst();
648
649 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
650 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
651
652 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
653 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
654
655 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
656 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
657 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
658
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000659 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000660 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000661 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000662 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
663 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000664 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000665 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000666 }
667
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000668 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000669}
670
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000671/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
672/// possibly a list of template arguments.
673///
674/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
675/// DecomposeTemplateName.
676///
677/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
678/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
679/// some way.
680static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
681 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
682 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
683 DeclarationName &Name,
684 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
685 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
686 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
687 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
688 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
689
690 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
691 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
692 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
693 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
694 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
695
696 TemplateName TName =
697 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
698
699 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
700 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
701 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
702 } else {
703 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
704 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
705 TemplateArgs = 0;
706 }
707}
708
709/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
710///
711/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
712/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
713/// found template arguments.
714static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
715 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
716 TemplateName TName =
717 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
718
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000719 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
720 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000721 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
722 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
723 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000724 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000725
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000726 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000727}
728
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000729/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
730/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
731/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000733 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
734 return false;
735
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000736 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
737 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
738 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
739 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
740 if (!BaseRT) return false;
741
742 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000743 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000744 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
745 return false;
746 }
747
748 return true;
749}
750
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000751/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
752/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
753static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000754 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000755
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000756 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
757 if (!DC) return true;
758
759 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
760 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
761
762 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
763 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765 return false;
766}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000767
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000768/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
769/// the prospective base classes.
770static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
771 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
772 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000773 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000774 return false;
775
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000776 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000777 if (!RD) return false;
778 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
779
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000780 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
781 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
782 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
783 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
784 if (!BaseRT) return false;
785
786 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
788 return false;
789 }
790
791 return true;
792}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000793
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794enum IMAKind {
795 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
796 IMA_Static,
797
798 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
799 IMA_Mixed,
800
801 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
802 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
803 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
804
805 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
806 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
807 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
808
809 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
810 IMA_Instance,
811
812 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
813 IMA_Unresolved,
814
815 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
816 /// context is not an instance method.
817 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
818
819 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
820 /// non-class context.
821 IMA_AnonymousMember,
822
823 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
824 /// context is not an instance method.
825 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
826
827 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
828 /// class.
829 IMA_Error_Unrelated
830};
831
832/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
833/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
834/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
835/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
836/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
837/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
838static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
839 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000840 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000841
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000842 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000843 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000844 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
845 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000846
847 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
848 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
849
850 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
851 bool hasNonInstance = false;
852 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
853 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000854 NamedDecl *D = *I;
855 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000856 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
857
858 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
859 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
860 // that's a special case.
861 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
862 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
863 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
864 }
865 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
866 }
867 else
868 hasNonInstance = true;
869 }
870
871 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
872 // member reference.
873 if (Classes.empty())
874 return IMA_Static;
875
876 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
877 // an implicit member reference.
878 if (isStaticContext)
879 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
880
881 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
882 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
883 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
884 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000885 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000886 Classes))
887 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
888
889 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
890}
891
892/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
893static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
894 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
895 const LookupResult &R) {
896 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
897 SourceRange Range(Loc);
898 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
899
900 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
901 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
902 if (MD->isStatic()) {
903 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
904 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
905 << Range << R.getLookupName();
906 return;
907 }
908 }
909
910 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
911 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
912 return;
913 }
914
915 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000916}
917
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000918/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
919///
920/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000921bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000922 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000923 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
924
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000926 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
928 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000929 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000930 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000931 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
932 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000933
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000934 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
935 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
936 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
937 // dependent name.
938 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
939 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000940 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
941 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
942
943 if (!R.empty()) {
944 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
945 R.suppressDiagnostics();
946
947 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
948 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
949 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
950 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
951
952 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
953 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
954 // Actually quite difficult!
955 if (isInstance)
956 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000957 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000958 else
959 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
960
961 // Do we really want to note all of these?
962 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
963 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
964
965 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
966 return false;
967 }
968 }
969 }
970
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000971 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000972 DeclarationName Corrected;
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000973 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000974 if (!R.empty()) {
975 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
976 if (SS.isEmpty())
977 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
978 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
979 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
980 else
981 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
982 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
983 << SS.getRange()
984 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
985 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
986 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
987 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
988 << ND->getDeclName();
989
990 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
991 return false;
992 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000993
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000994 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
995 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
996 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
997 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
998 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
999 // to recover well anyway.
1000 if (SS.isEmpty())
1001 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
1002 else
1003 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1004 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1005 << SS.getRange();
1006
1007 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1008 return true;
1009 }
1010 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001011 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001012 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001013 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001014 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001015 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001016 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001017 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1018 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001019 return true;
1020 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001021 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001022 }
1023
1024 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1025 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1026 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1027 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1028 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1029 << SS.getRange();
1030 return true;
1031 }
1032
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001033 // Give up, we can't recover.
1034 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1035 return true;
1036}
1037
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001038Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001039 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001040 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1041 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1042 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1043 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1044 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1045
1046 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001047 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001048
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001049 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001050
1051 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1052 DeclarationName Name;
1053 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1054 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001055 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1056 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001057
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001058 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001059
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001060 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1061 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001062 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1063 // (note: handled after lookup)
1064 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1065 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1066 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001067 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1068 // names a dependent type.
1069 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1070 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001071 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1072 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1073 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001074 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001075 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076 TemplateArgs);
1077 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001078
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079 // Perform the required lookup.
1080 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1081 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001082 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1083 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1084 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1085 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1086 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
1087 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001088 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001089 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1090 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001091
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001092 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1093 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001094 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1095 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 if (E.isInvalid())
1097 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001098
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001099 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1100 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001101 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001102 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001103
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001104 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1105 return ExprError();
1106
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001107 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1108 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001109 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001110
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001111 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001112 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001113 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1114 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1115 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1116 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1117 }
1118
1119 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1120 // call, diagnose the problem.
1121 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001122 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001123 return ExprError();
1124
1125 assert(!R.empty() &&
1126 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001127
1128 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1129 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001130 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001131 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1132 R.clear();
1133 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1134 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1135 return move(E);
1136 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001137 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001138 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001139
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1141 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1142
1143 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 // Warn about constructs like:
1145 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1146 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001147 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1148 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001149 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001150 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001151 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001152 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001153 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001154 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1155 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001156 break;
1157 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001158
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001159 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1160 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001161 }
1162 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001164 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1165 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1166 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1167 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1168 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1169 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001171 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001172
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001173 QualType T = Func->getType();
1174 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001175 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001176 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1177 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001178 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001179 }
1180 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001181
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001182 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1183 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1184 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1185 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1186 // class member access expression.
1187 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1188 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001189 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001190 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001191 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1192 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001193 }
1194
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001195 if (TemplateArgs)
1196 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001197
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001198 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1199}
1200
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001201/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1202Sema::OwningExprResult
1203Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1204 LookupResult &R,
1205 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1206 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1207 case IMA_Instance:
1208 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1209
1210 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1211 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1212 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1213 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1214
1215 case IMA_Mixed:
1216 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1217 case IMA_Unresolved:
1218 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1219
1220 case IMA_Static:
1221 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1222 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1223 if (TemplateArgs)
1224 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1225 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1226
1227 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1228 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1229 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1230 return ExprError();
1231 }
1232
1233 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1234 return ExprError();
1235}
1236
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001237/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1238/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1239/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1240/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001241Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001242Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001243 DeclarationName Name,
1244 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1245 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001246 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001247 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1248
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001249 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001250 return ExprError();
1251
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001252 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1253 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1254
1255 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1256 return ExprError();
1257
1258 if (R.empty()) {
1259 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1260 return ExprError();
1261 }
1262
1263 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1264}
1265
1266/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1267/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1268/// additional lookup.
1269///
1270/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1271/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1272///
1273/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1274Sema::OwningExprResult
1275Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001276 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001277 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001278 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001279
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001280 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1281 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1282 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1283 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1284 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1285
1286 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1287 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1288 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001289 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001290
1291 bool LookForIvars;
1292 if (Lookup.empty())
1293 LookForIvars = true;
1294 else if (IsClassMethod)
1295 LookForIvars = false;
1296 else
1297 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1298 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001299 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001300 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001301 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001302 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1303 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1304 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1305 if (IsClassMethod)
1306 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1307 << IV->getDeclName());
1308
1309 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1310 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1311 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1312 return ExprError();
1313
1314 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1315 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1316 return ExprError();
1317
1318 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1319 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1320 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1321 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1322
1323 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1324 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1325 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1326 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001327 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001328 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1329 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1330 SelfName, false, false);
1331 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1332 return Owned(new (Context)
1333 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1334 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1335 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001336 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001337 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001338 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001339 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1340 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1341 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1342 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1343 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1344 }
1345 }
1346
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001347 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1348 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1349 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1350 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1351 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1352 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1353 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1354 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1355 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1356 }
1357 }
1358 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001359 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1360 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001361}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001362
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001363/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1364///
1365/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1366///
1367/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1368/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1369/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1370/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1371///
1372/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1373/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1374/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1375/// the class declaring the member.
1376///
1377/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1378/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1379/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001380bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001381Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1382 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001383 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001384 NamedDecl *Member) {
1385 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1386 if (!RD)
1387 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001388
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001389 QualType DestRecordType;
1390 QualType DestType;
1391 QualType FromRecordType;
1392 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1393 bool PointerConversions = false;
1394 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1395 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001396
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001397 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1398 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1399 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1400 PointerConversions = true;
1401 } else {
1402 DestType = DestRecordType;
1403 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001404 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001405 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1406 if (Method->isStatic())
1407 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001408
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001409 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1410 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001411
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001412 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1413 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1414 PointerConversions = true;
1415 } else {
1416 FromRecordType = FromType;
1417 DestType = DestRecordType;
1418 }
1419 } else {
1420 // No conversion necessary.
1421 return false;
1422 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001423
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001424 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1425 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001426
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001427 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1428 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1429 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001430
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001431 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1432 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1433
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001434 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001435 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001436 // class name.
1437 //
1438 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1439 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1440 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1441 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1442 //
1443 // class Base { public: int x; };
1444 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1445 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1446 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1447 //
1448 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1449 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1450 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1451 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001452 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001453 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1454 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1455 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1456
1457 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1458
1459 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1460 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1461 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1462 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001463 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001464 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001465 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001466 return true;
1467
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001468 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001469 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001470 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001471 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001472
1473 FromType = QType;
1474 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1475
1476 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1477 // we're done.
1478 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1479 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001480 }
1481 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001482
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001483 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001484
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001485 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1486 // down to the using declaration's type.
1487 //
1488 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1489 // class ever has member declarations.
1490 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1491 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1492 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1493 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1494
1495 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1496 // conversion is non-trivial.
1497 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1498 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001499 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001500 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001501 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001502 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001503
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001504 QualType UType = URecordType;
1505 if (PointerConversions)
1506 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001507 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001508 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509 FromType = UType;
1510 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1511 }
1512
1513 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1514 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1515 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001517
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001518 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1519 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1520 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001521 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001522 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001523
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001524 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001525 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001526 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001527}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001528
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001529/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001530static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001531 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001532 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1533 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001534 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1535 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1536 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001537 if (SS.isSet()) {
1538 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1539 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001540 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001541
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001542 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001543 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001544}
1545
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001546/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1547/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1548/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1549/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001550Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001551Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1552 LookupResult &R,
1553 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1554 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001555 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1556
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001557 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001558
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001559 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1560 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001561 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001562 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001563 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001564 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001565 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001566
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001567 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1568 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001569 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1570 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001571 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1572 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001573 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1574 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1575 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1576 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001577 }
1578
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001579 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1580 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1581 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001582 SS,
1583 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1584 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001585}
1586
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001587bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001588 const LookupResult &R,
1589 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001590 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1591 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1592 return false;
1593
1594 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001595 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001596 return false;
1597
1598 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001599 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001600 return false;
1601
1602 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1603 // normal lookup:
1604 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1605 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1606
1607 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1608 // -- a declaration of a class member
1609 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1610 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001611 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001612 return false;
1613
1614 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1615 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1616 // using-declaration
1617 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1618 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1619 // turn off ADL anyway).
1620 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1621 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1622 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1623 return false;
1624
1625 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1626 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1627 // template
1628 // And also for builtin functions.
1629 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1630 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1631
1632 // But also builtin functions.
1633 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1634 return false;
1635 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1636 return false;
1637 }
1638
1639 return true;
1640}
1641
1642
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001643/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1644/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1645/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1646/// will in fact be used.
1647static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1648 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1649 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1650 return true;
1651 }
1652
1653 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1654 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1655 return true;
1656 }
1657
1658 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1659 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1660 return true;
1661 }
1662
1663 return false;
1664}
1665
1666Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001667Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001668 LookupResult &R,
1669 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001670 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1671 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001672 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001673 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674
1675 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1676 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1677 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001678 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1679 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 return ExprError();
1681
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001682 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1683 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1684 // we've picked a target.
1685 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1686
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001687 bool Dependent
1688 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001689 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001690 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001691 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1692 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001693 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1694 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001695 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696
1697 return Owned(ULE);
1698}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001699
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001700
1701/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1702Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001703Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001704 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1705 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001706 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1707 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001708
1709 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1710 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001711
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001712 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1713 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1714 // a template argument list.
1715 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1716 << Template << SS.getRange();
1717 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1718 return ExprError();
1719 }
1720
1721 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1722 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1723 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001724 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001725 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001726 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001727 return ExprError();
1728 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001729
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001730 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1731 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1732 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1733 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001734 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001735 return ExprError();
1736
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001737 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1738 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001739 return ExprError();
1740
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001741 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1742 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1743 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1744 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001745 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001746 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1747 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1748 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001749 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001750 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001751 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1752 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1753 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1754 return ExprError();
1755 }
1756
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001757 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001758 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1759 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1760 return ExprError();
1761 }
1762
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001763 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001764 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001765 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001766 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001767 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001768 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1769 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001770 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001771
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001772 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001773 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001774 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001775 }
1776 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1777 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001778
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001779 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001780}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001781
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001782Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1783 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001784 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001785
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001786 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001787 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001788 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1789 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1790 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001791 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001792
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001793 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1794 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001795
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001796 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1797 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001798 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001799 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001800 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001802 QualType ResTy;
1803 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1804 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1805 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001806 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001807
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001808 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001809 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001810 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1811 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001812 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001813}
1814
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001816 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001817 bool Invalid = false;
1818 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1819 if (Invalid)
1820 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001821
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001822 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1823 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001824 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001825 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001826
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001827 QualType Ty;
1828 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1829 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1830 else if (Literal.isWide())
1831 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001832 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1833 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001834 else
1835 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001836
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001837 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1838 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001839 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001840}
1841
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1843 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001844 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1845 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001846 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001847 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001848 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001849 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001850 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001851
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001852 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001853 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1854 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001855 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001856
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001857 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001858 bool Invalid = false;
1859 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1860 if (Invalid)
1861 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001862
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001863 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001864 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001865 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001866 return ExprError();
1867
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001868 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001869
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001870 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001871 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001872 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001873 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001874 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001875 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001876 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001877 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001878
1879 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1880
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001881 using llvm::APFloat;
1882 APFloat Val(Format);
1883
1884 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001885
1886 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1887 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1888 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1889 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001890 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001891 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001892 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001893 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001894 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1895 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001896 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001897 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1898 }
1899
1900 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1901 << Ty
1902 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1903 }
1904
1905 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001906 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001907
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001908 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001909 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001910 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001911 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001912
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001913 // long long is a C99 feature.
1914 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001915 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001916 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1917
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001918 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001919 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001920
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001921 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1922 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1923 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001924 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1925 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001926 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001927 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001928 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1929 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001930
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001931 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1932 // be an unsigned int.
1933 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1934
1935 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001936 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001937 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1938 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001939 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001940
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001941 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1942 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1943 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1944 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001945 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001946 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001947 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001948 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001949 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001950 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001951
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001952 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001953 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001954 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001955
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001956 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1957 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1958 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1959 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001960 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001964 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965 }
1966
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001967 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001968 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001969 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001970
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001971 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1972 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1973 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1974 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001975 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001976 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001977 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001978 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001979 }
1980 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001981
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001982 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1983 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001984 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001985 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001986 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001987 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001988 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001989
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001990 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1991 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001992 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001993 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001994 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001995
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001996 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1997 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001998 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001999 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002000
2001 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002002}
2003
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002004Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2005 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002006 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002007 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002008 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002009}
2010
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002011/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002012/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002013bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002014 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2015 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2016 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002017 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2018 return false;
2019
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002020 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2021 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2022 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2023 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2024 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2025 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2026
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002027 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002028 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002029 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002030 if (isSizeof)
2031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2032 return false;
2033 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002034
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002035 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002036 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002037 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2038 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002039 return false;
2040 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002041
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002042 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002043 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2044 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002045 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002046
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002047 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002048 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002049 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002050 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2051 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002052 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002053
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002054 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002055}
2056
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002057bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2058 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2059 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002060
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002061 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2063 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002064
2065 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2066 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2067 return false;
2068
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002069 if (E->getBitField()) {
2070 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2071 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002072 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002073
2074 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2075 // bit-field.
2076 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002077 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002078 return false;
2079
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002080 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2081}
2082
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002083/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002084Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002085Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002086 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002087 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002088 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 return ExprError();
2090
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002091 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002092
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002093 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2094 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2095 return ExprError();
2096
2097 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002098 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002099 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2100 R.getEnd()));
2101}
2102
2103/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2104/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002105Action::OwningExprResult
2106Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002107 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2108 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2109 bool isInvalid = false;
2110 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2111 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2112 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2113 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002114 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002115 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2116 isInvalid = true;
2117 } else {
2118 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2119 }
2120
2121 if (isInvalid)
2122 return ExprError();
2123
2124 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2125 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2126 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2127 R.getEnd()));
2128}
2129
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002130/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2131/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2132/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002133Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002134Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2135 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002136 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002137 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002138
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002139 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002140 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2141 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2142 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002144
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002145 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2146 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2147 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2148
2149 if (Result.isInvalid())
2150 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2151
2152 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002153}
2154
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002155QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002156 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2157 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002159 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002160 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002161 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002162
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002163 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2164 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2165 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002166
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002167 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002168 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2169 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002170 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002171}
2172
2173
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002174
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002175Action::OwningExprResult
2176Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2177 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002178 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2179 switch (Kind) {
2180 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2181 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2182 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2183 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002184
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002185 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002186}
2187
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002188Action::OwningExprResult
2189Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2190 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002191 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2192 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2193
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002194 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2195 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002196
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002197 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002198 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2199 Base.release();
2200 Idx.release();
2201 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2202 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2203 }
2204
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002205 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002206 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002207 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2208 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2209 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002210 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002211 }
2212
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002213 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2214}
2215
2216
2217Action::OwningExprResult
2218Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2219 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2220 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2221 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2222
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002224 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2225 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2226 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002227
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002229
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002230 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002231 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002232 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002233 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002234 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2235 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002236 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2237 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2238 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2239 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002240 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002241 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2242 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002243 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002244 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002245 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2247 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002248 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002249 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002250 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002251 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2252 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2253 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002254 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002255 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002256 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2257 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2258 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2259 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002260 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002261 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002262 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002263
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002264 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2265 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002266 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2267 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002268 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2270 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2271 // force the promotion here.
2272 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2273 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002274 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2275 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002276 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2277
2278 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2279 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002280 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002281 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2282 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2283 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2284 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002285 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2286 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002287 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2288
2289 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2290 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002291 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002292 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002293 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2294 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002295 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002296 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002297 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2298 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002299 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2300 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002301
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002302 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002303 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2304 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002305 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2306
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002307 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2309 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002310 // incomplete types are not object types.
2311 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2312 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2313 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2314 return ExprError();
2315 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002317 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002318 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002319 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2320 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002321 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002322
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002323 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002324 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002325 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2326 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2327 return ExprError();
2328 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002329
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002330 Base.release();
2331 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002332 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002333 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002334}
2335
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002336QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002337CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002338 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002339 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002340 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2341 // see FIXME there.
2342 //
2343 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2344 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002345 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002346
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002347 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002348 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002349
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002350 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002351 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2352 // to be selected.
2353 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002354
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2356 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002357 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002358
2359 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2360 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002361 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002362 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2363 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002364 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002365 do
2366 compStr++;
2367 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002368 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002369 do
2370 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002371 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002372 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002373
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002374 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002375 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2376 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002377 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2378 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002379 return QualType();
2380 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002381
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002382 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2383 // operates on.
2384 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002385 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002386
2387 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002388 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002389
2390 while (*compStr) {
2391 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2392 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2393 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2394 return QualType();
2395 }
2396 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002397 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002398
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002399 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002400 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002401 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002402 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002403 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002404 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002405 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002406 if (HexSwizzle)
2407 CompSize--;
2408
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002409 if (CompSize == 1)
2410 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002411
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002412 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002413 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002414 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2415 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2416 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2417 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002418 }
2419 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002420}
2421
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002422static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002423 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002424 const Selector &Sel,
2425 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002426
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002427 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002428 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002429 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002431
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2433 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002434 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002435 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002436 return D;
2437 }
2438 return 0;
2439}
2440
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002441static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002442 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002443 const Selector &Sel,
2444 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002445 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2446 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002447 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002448 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002449 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002450 GDecl = PD;
2451 break;
2452 }
2453 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002454 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002455 GDecl = OMD;
2456 break;
2457 }
2458 }
2459 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002460 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002461 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2462 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002463 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002464 if (GDecl)
2465 return GDecl;
2466 }
2467 }
2468 return GDecl;
2469}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002470
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002471Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002472Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2473 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002474 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2475 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2476 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2477 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2478 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2479
2480 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2481 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2482 //
2483 // T* t;
2484 // t.f;
2485 //
2486 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2487 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2488 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2489 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002490 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002491 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2492 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002493 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002494 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002495 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496 return ExprError();
2497 }
2498 }
2499
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002500 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002501 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002502
2503 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2504 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002505 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002506 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2507 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2508 SS.getRange(),
2509 FirstQualifierInScope,
2510 Name, NameLoc,
2511 TemplateArgs));
2512}
2513
2514/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2515/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2516/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2517static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2518 Expr *BaseExpr,
2519 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002520 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002521 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002522 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2523 // diagnostics.
2524 if (!BaseExpr)
2525 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002526
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002527 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2528 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002529}
2530
2531// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2532// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2533// type. The restriction here is:
2534//
2535// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2536// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2537// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2538//
2539// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2540// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2541// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2542// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2543bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2544 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002545 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002546 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002547 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2548 if (!BaseRT) {
2549 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2550 // dependent.
2551 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2552 return false;
2553 }
2554 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002555
2556 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2558 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002559 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002560 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002561
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002562 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2563 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2564 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2565 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2566
2567 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2568 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2569
2570 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2571 return false;
2572 }
2573
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002574 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002575 return true;
2576}
2577
2578static bool
2579LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2580 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002581 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002582 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2583 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002584 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002585 << BaseRange))
2586 return true;
2587
2588 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2589 if (SS.isSet()) {
2590 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2591 // nested-name-specifier.
2592 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2593
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002594 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002595 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2596 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2597 return true;
2598 }
2599
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002600 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002601
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002602 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2603 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2604 << DC << SS.getRange();
2605 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002606 }
2607 }
2608
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002609 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2610 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002611
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002612 if (!R.empty())
2613 return false;
2614
2615 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2616 // for typos.
2617 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002618 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002619 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002620 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2621 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2622 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002623 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2624 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002625 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2626 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2627 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002628 return false;
2629 } else {
2630 R.clear();
2631 }
2632
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002633 return false;
2634}
2635
2636Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002637Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002638 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002639 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002640 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2641 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2642 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2643 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2644
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002645 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2646 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002647 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2649 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2650 Name, NameLoc,
2651 TemplateArgs);
2652
2653 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002654
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002655 // Implicit member accesses.
2656 if (!Base) {
2657 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2658 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2659 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2660 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2661 OpLoc, SS))
2662 return ExprError();
2663
2664 // Explicit member accesses.
2665 } else {
2666 OwningExprResult Result =
2667 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002668 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002669
2670 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2671 Owned(Base);
2672 return ExprError();
2673 }
2674
2675 if (Result.get())
2676 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002677
2678 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2679 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002680 }
2681
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002682 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002683 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2684 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002685}
2686
2687Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2689 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2690 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002691 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002692 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002693 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2694 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002695 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002696 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697 if (IsArrow) {
2698 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2699 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2700 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002701 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002702
2703 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2704 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2705 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2706 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2707
2708 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002709 return ExprError();
2710
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002711 if (R.empty()) {
2712 // Rederive where we looked up.
2713 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2714 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2715 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002716
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002717 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002718 << MemberName << DC
2719 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002720 return ExprError();
2721 }
2722
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002723 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2724 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2725 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2726 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2727 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2728 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2729 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2730 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2731 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2732 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002733 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002734 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002735 return ExprError();
2736
2737 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2738 // result.
2739 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002740 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002741 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002742 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002743 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002744
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002745 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2746 // pick a member.
2747 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2748
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002749 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2750 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2751 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002752 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2753 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002754 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2755 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2756 TemplateArgs);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002757 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002758
2759 return Owned(MemExpr);
2760 }
2761
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002762 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002763 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2765
2766 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2767
2768 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2769 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2770 // error cases.
2771 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2772 return ExprError();
2773
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002774 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2775 if (!BaseExpr) {
2776 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002777 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002778 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2779
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002780 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2781 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2782 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2783 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002784 }
2785
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002786 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2787 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2788 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2789 // explicitly qualified.
2790 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2791 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2792 }
2793
2794 // Check the use of this member.
2795 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2796 Owned(BaseExpr);
2797 return ExprError();
2798 }
2799
2800 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2801 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2802 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002803 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2804 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2806 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2807
2808 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2809 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2810 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2811 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2812 else {
2813 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2814 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2815 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2816
2817 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2818 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2819
2820 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2821 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2822 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2823 }
2824
2825 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002826 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827 return ExprError();
2828 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002829 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830 }
2831
2832 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2833 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2834 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002835 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2837 }
2838
2839 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2840 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2841 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002842 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002843 MemberFn->getType()));
2844 }
2845
2846 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2847 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2848 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002849 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002850 }
2851
2852 Owned(BaseExpr);
2853
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002854 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002855 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002856 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2857 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2858 else
2859 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2860 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002861
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002862 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2863 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002864 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002865 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866}
2867
2868/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2869/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2870/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2871/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2872/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2873/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2874/// an ordinary member expression.
2875///
2876/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2877/// fixed for ObjC++.
2878Sema::OwningExprResult
2879Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002880 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002881 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002882 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002883 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002884
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002885 // Perform default conversions.
2886 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002887
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002888 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002889 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2890
2891 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2892 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002893
2894 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002896 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2897 // call, and continue on.
2898 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2899 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2900 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2901 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2902 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002903 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2904 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002905 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2906 ->isRecordType()))) {
2907 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2908 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2909 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002910 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002911
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002912 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002913 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002914 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2915 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002916 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002917
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002918 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2919 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2920 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2921 }
2922 }
2923 }
2924
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002925 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2926 // use that.
2927 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002928 if (IsArrow) {
2929 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2930 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2931 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002932 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002933 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002934 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2935 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002936 }
2937 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002938 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2939 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2940 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2941 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002942 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002943 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002944 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002945
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002946 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2947 // use that.
2948 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2949 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2950 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2951 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2952 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2953 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2954 }
2955 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002956
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002957 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002958
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002959 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002960 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002961 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2962 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2963 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2964 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2965 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2966 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2967 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2968 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2969 // Check the use of this method.
2970 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2971 return ExprError();
2972 }
2973 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2974 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2975 Selector SetterSel =
2976 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2977 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2978 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2979 if (!Setter) {
2980 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2981 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002982 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002983 }
2984 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2985 if (!Setter)
2986 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002987
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002988 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2989 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002990
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002991 if (Getter || Setter) {
2992 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002993
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002994 if (Getter)
2995 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2996 else
2997 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2998 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2999 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003000 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003001 PType,
3002 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3003 }
3004 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3005 << MemberName << BaseType);
3006 }
3007 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003008
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003009 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3010 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3011 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003012 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003013 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003014
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003015 if (IsArrow) {
3016 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003017 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003018 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3019 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003020 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3021 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3022 // struct MyRecord foo;
3023 // foo->bar
3024 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3025 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3026 // by now.
3027 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3028 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003029 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003030 IsArrow = false;
3031 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003032 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3033 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3034 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003035 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003036 } else {
3037 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3038 // type *foo;
3039 // foo.bar
3040 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3041 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3042 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3043 // the appropriate pointer type
3044 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3045 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3046 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3047 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3048 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003049 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003050 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3051 IsArrow = true;
3052 }
3053 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003054 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003055
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003056 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003057 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003058 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3059 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003060 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003061 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003062 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003063
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003064 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3065 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003067 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003068 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003069 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3070 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3071 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3072 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003073 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3074
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003075 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003076 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003077
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003078 if (!IV) {
3079 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3080 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3081 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003082 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003083 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003084 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003085 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3086 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003087 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3088 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003089 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003090 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003091 }
3092 }
3093
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003094 if (IV) {
3095 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3096 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3097 // error cases.
3098 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3099 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003100
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003101 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3102 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3103 return ExprError();
3104 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3105 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3106 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3107 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3108 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3109 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3110 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3111 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3112 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3113 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3114 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3115 // AST for a function decl.
3116 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003117 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003118 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3119 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3120 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3121 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3122 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3123 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124
3125 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3126 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003127 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003128 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003129 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003130 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3131 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003132 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003133 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003134 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003135
3136 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3137 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003138 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003139 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003140 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003141 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003142 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003143 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003144 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003145 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003146 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3147 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003148 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003149 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003150
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003151 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003152 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003153 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3154 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3155 // Check the use of this declaration
3156 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3157 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003158
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003159 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3160 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3161 }
3162 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3163 // Check the use of this method.
3164 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3165 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003166
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003167 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003168 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3169 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3170 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003171 }
3172 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003173
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003174 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003175 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003176 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003177
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003178 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3179 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003180 if (!IsArrow)
3181 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3182 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003183 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003184
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003185 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003186 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003187 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3188 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003189 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003190 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003191 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003192
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003193 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003194 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003195 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003196 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3197 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003198 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003199 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003200 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003201 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003202
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003203 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3204 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3205
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003206 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003207}
3208
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003209/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3210/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3211/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3212/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3213/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3214///
3215/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3216/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3217/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3218/// only be called
3219/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3220/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3221/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3222Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3223 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3224 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003225 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003226 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3227 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3228 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3229 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3230 return ExprError();
3231
3232 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3233
3234 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3235 DeclarationName Name;
3236 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3237 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3238 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3239 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3240
3241 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3242
3243 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3244 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3245 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3246
3247 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3248 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3249
3250 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3251 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003252 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3253 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003254 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003255 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3256 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3257 Name, NameLoc,
3258 TemplateArgs);
3259 } else {
3260 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3261 if (TemplateArgs) {
3262 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3263 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003264
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003265 // Re-derive the naming class.
3266 if (SS.isSet()) {
3267 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3268 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3269 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3270 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3271 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3272 } else {
3273 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3274 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3275 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3276 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3277 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3278 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003279 } else {
3280 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003281 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003282
3283 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3284 Owned(Base);
3285 return ExprError();
3286 }
3287
3288 if (Result.get()) {
3289 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3290 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3291 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3292 // call now.
3293 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3294 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003295 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003296
3297 return move(Result);
3298 }
3299 }
3300
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003301 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003302 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3303 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003304 }
3305
3306 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003307}
3308
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003309Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3310 FunctionDecl *FD,
3311 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3312 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3313 Diag (CallLoc,
3314 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3315 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003316 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003317 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3318 } else {
3319 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3320 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3321
3322 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003323 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3324 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003325
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003326 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3327 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003328 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003329
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003330 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003331 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003332 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003333
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003334 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3335 InitializedEntity Entity
3336 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3337 InitializationKind Kind
3338 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3339 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3340 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3341
3342 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003343 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003344 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3345 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003346 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003347
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003348 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003349 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003350 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003351 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003352
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003353 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3354 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3355 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003356 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3357 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003358 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3359 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003360 }
3361
3362 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003363 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003364}
3365
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003366/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3367/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3368/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3369/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3370/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3371/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003372bool
3373Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003374 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003375 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003376 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3377 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003378 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003379 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3380 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003381 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003382
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003383 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3384 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3385 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3386 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3387 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003388 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003389 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003390 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003391 }
3392
3393 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3394 // them.
3395 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3396 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3397 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3398 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003399 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003400 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003401 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3402 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3403 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003404 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003405 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003406 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003407 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003408 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003409 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003410 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3411 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3412 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3413 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3414 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003415 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003416 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003417 if (Invalid)
3418 return true;
3419 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3420 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3421 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003422
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003423 return false;
3424}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003425
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003426bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3427 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3428 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3429 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3430 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3431 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003432 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003433 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3434 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3435 bool Invalid = false;
3436 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3437 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3438 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3439 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003440 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003441 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003442 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003443
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003444 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003445 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3446 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003447
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003448 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3449 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003450 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003451 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003452 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003453
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003454 // Pass the argument
3455 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3456 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3457 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003458
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003459
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003460 InitializedEntity Entity =
3461 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3462 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3463 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3464 SourceLocation(),
3465 Owned(Arg));
3466 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3467 return true;
3468
3469 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003470 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003471 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003472
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003473 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003474 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003475 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3476 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003477
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003478 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003479 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003480 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003481 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003482
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003483 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003484 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003485 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003486 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003488 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003489 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003490 }
3491 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003492 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003493}
3494
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003495/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003496/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3497/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003498Action::OwningExprResult
3499Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3500 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003501 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003502 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003503
3504 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3505 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003506
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003507 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003508 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003509 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003510
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003511 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003512 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3513 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3514 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3515 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3516 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003517 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003518 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3519 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003520
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003521 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3522 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003523
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003524 NumArgs = 0;
3525 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003526
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003527 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3528 RParenLoc));
3529 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003530
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003531 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003532 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003533 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3534 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003535 bool Dependent = false;
3536 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3537 Dependent = true;
3538 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3539 Dependent = true;
3540
3541 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003542 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003543 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3544
3545 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3546 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3547 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3548 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3549
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003550 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3551
3552 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3553 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3554 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3555 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3556 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3557 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3558 // method template.
3559 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003560 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3561 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003562 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003563
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003564 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3565 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003566 }
3567
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003568 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003569 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003570 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003571 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003572 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3573 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003574 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003575
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003576 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003577 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003578 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3579 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003580 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3581 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003582 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003583
3584 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3585 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003586 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3587 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003588
3589 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3590 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003591 TheCall.get(), 0))
3592 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003593
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003594 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003595 RParenLoc))
3596 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003597
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003598 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3599 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003600 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003601 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3602 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003603 }
3604 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003605 }
3606
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003607 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003608 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003609 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003610
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003611 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003612 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3613 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003614 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003615 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003616 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003617
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003618 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3619 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3620 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3621
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003622 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3623}
3624
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003625/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3626/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003627/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3628/// block-pointer type.
3629///
3630/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3631Sema::OwningExprResult
3632Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3633 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3634 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3635 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3636 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3637
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003638 // Promote the function operand.
3639 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3640
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003641 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3642 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003643 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3644 Args, NumArgs,
3645 Context.BoolTy,
3646 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003647
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003648 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3649 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3650 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3651 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003652 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003653 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003654 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3655 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003656 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003657 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003658 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003659 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003660 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003661 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003662 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3663 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3664
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003665 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003666 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003667 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3668 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003669 return ExprError();
3670
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003671 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003672 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003673
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003674 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003675 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003676 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003677 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003678 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003679 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003680
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003681 if (FDecl) {
3682 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3683 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3684 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003685 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003686 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003687 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003688 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3689 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3690 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3691 }
3692 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003693 }
3694
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003695 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003696 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3697 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3698 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003699 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3700 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003701 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3702 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003703 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003704 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003705 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003706 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003707
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003708 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3709 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003710 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3711 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003712
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003713 // Check for sentinels
3714 if (NDecl)
3715 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003716
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003717 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003718 if (FDecl) {
3719 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3720 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003721
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003722 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003723 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3724 } else if (NDecl) {
3725 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3726 return ExprError();
3727 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003728
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003729 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003730}
3731
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003732Action::OwningExprResult
3733Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3734 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003735 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003736 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003737 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003738
3739 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3740 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3741 if (!TInfo)
3742 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3743
3744 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3745}
3746
3747Action::OwningExprResult
3748Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3749 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3750 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003751 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003752
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003753 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003754 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003755 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3756 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003757 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3758 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003759 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003760 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003761 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003762 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003763
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003764 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003765 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003766 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003767 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003768 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003769 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3770 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3771 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3772 &literalType);
3773 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003774 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003775 InitExpr.release();
3776 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003777
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003778 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003779 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003780 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003781 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003782 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003783
3784 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003785
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003786 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003787 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003788}
3789
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003790Action::OwningExprResult
3791Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003792 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3793 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3794 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003795
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003796 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003797 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003798
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003799 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3800 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003801 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003802 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003803}
3804
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003805static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3806 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003807 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003808 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3809
3810 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3811 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003812 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3813 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003814 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003815 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3816 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3817 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003818
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003819 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3820 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3821 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3822 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3823 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3824 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3825 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3826 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003827
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003828 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3829 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3830 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3831 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3832 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3833 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003834
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003835 // FIXME: Assert here.
3836 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3837 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3838}
3839
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003840/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003841bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003842 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003843 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003844 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003845 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003846 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3847 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003848
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003849 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003850
3851 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3852 // type needs to be scalar.
3853 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3854 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003855 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3856 return false;
3857 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003858
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003859 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003860 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003861 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3862 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003863 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003864 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3865 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003866 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003867 return false;
3868 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003869
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003870 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003871 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003872 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003873 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003874 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003875 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003876 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003877 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003878 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3879 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3880 break;
3881 }
3882 }
3883 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3884 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3885 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003886 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003887 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003888 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003889
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003890 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3891 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3892 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3893 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003894
3895 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003896 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003897 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3898 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003899 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003900 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003901
3902 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003903 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003904
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003905 if (castType->isVectorType())
3906 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3907 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3908 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3909
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003910 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3911 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003912
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003913 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003914 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3915 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3916 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3917 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3918 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3919 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3920 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3921 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3922 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3923 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003924 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003925
3926 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003927 return false;
3928}
3929
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003930bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3931 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003932 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003933
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003934 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003935 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003936 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003937 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003938 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003939 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003940 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003941 } else
3942 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003943 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003944 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003945
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003946 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003947 return false;
3948}
3949
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003950bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003951 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003952 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003953
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003954 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003955
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003956 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3957 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003958 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3959 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3960 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3961 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003962 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003963 return false;
3964 }
3965
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003966 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003967 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3968 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003969 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3970 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3971 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3972 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003973
3974 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3975 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3976 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003977
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003978 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003979 return false;
3980}
3981
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003982Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003983Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003984 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3985 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3986 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003987
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003988 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3989 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3990 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003991 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003992
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003993 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003994 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003995 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003996 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3997 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003998
3999 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4000}
4001
4002Action::OwningExprResult
4003Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4004 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4005 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4006
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004007 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004008 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004009 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004010 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004011 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004012
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004013 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004014 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004015 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004016 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004017}
4018
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004019/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4020/// of comma binary operators.
4021Action::OwningExprResult
4022Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4023 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4024 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4025 if (!E)
4026 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004027
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004028 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004029
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004030 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4031 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4032 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004033
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004034 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4035}
4036
4037Action::OwningExprResult
4038Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4039 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004040 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004041 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004042 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004043
4044 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004045 // then handle it as such.
4046 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4047 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4048 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4049 return ExprError();
4050 }
4051
4052 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4053 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4054 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4055
4056 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4057 // braces instead of the original commas.
4058 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004059 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4060 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004061 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4062 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004063 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004064 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004065 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004066 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4067 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004068 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004069 }
4070}
4071
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004072Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004073 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004074 MultiExprArg Val,
4075 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004076 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4077 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004078 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4079 Expr *expr;
4080 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4081 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4082 else
4083 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004084 return Owned(expr);
4085}
4086
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004087/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4088/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004089/// C99 6.5.15
4090QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4091 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004092 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4093 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4094 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4095
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004096 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4097 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4098 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4099 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4100 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4101 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004102
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004103 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004104 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4105 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4106 << CondTy;
4107 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004108 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004109
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004110 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004111 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4112 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004113
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004114 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4115 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004116 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4117 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4118 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004119 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004120
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004121 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4122 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004123 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4124 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004125 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004126 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004127 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004128 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004129 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004130 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004131
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004132 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004133 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004134 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4135 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4136 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4137 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4138 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4139 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4140 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004141 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4142 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004143 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004144 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004145 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4146 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004147 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004148 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004149 // promote the null to a pointer.
4150 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004151 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004152 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004153 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004154 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004155 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004156 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004157 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004158
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004159 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4160 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4161 QuestionLoc);
4162 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4163 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004164
4165
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004166 // Handle block pointer types.
4167 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4168 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4169 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4170 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004171 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4172 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004173 return destType;
4174 }
4175 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004176 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004177 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004178 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004179 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4180 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4181 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004182 return LHSTy;
4183 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004184 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004185 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4186 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004187
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004188 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4189 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004190 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004191 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004192 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4193 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4194 // to get a consistent AST.
4195 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004196 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4197 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004198 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004199 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004200 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004201 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4202 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004203 return LHSTy;
4204 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004205
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004206 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4207 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4208 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004209 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4210 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004211
4212 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4213 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4214 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004215 QualType destPointee
4216 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004217 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004218 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4219 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4220 // Promote to void*.
4221 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004222 return destType;
4223 }
4224 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004225 QualType destPointee
4226 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004227 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004228 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004229 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004230 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004231 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004232 return destType;
4233 }
4234
4235 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4236 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4237 return LHSTy;
4238 }
4239 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4240 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4241 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4242 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4243 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4244 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4245 // to get a consistent AST.
4246 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004247 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4248 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004249 return incompatTy;
4250 }
4251 // The pointer types are compatible.
4252 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4253 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4254 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4255 // type.
4256 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4257 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004258 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4259 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004260 return LHSTy;
4261 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004262
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004263 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4264 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4265 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4266 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004267 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004268 return RHSTy;
4269 }
4270 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4271 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4272 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004273 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004274 return LHSTy;
4275 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004276
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004277 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004278 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4279 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004280 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004281}
4282
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004283/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4284/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4285QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4286 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4287 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4288 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004289
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004290 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4291 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4292 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4293 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4294 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4295 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4296 return LHSTy;
4297 }
4298 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4299 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4300 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4301 return RHSTy;
4302 }
4303 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4304 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4305 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4306 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4307 return LHSTy;
4308 }
4309 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4310 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4311 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4312 return RHSTy;
4313 }
4314 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4315 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4316 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4317 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4318 return LHSTy;
4319 }
4320 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4321 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4322 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4323 return RHSTy;
4324 }
4325 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4326 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004327
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004328 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4329 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4330 return LHSTy;
4331 }
4332 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4333 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4334 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004335
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004336 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4337 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4338 // type. This allows
4339 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4340 // where B is a subclass of A.
4341 //
4342 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4343 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4344 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4345 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004346
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004347 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4348 // It could return the composite type.
4349 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4350 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4351 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4352 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4353 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4354 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4355 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4356 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4357 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4358 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4359 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4360 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4361 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4362 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004363 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004364 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4365 ;
4366 else {
4367 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4368 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4369 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4370 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4371 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4372 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4373 return incompatTy;
4374 }
4375 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4376 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4377 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return compositeType;
4379 }
4380 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4381 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4382 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4383 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4384 QualType destPointee
4385 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4386 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4387 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4388 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4389 // Promote to void*.
4390 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4391 return destType;
4392 }
4393 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4394 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4395 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4396 QualType destPointee
4397 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4398 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4399 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4400 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4401 // Promote to void*.
4402 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4403 return destType;
4404 }
4405 return QualType();
4406}
4407
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004408/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004409/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004410Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4411 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4412 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4413 ExprArg RHS) {
4414 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4415 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004416
4417 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4418 // was the condition.
4419 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4420 if (isLHSNull)
4421 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004422
4423 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004424 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004425 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004426 return ExprError();
4427
4428 Cond.release();
4429 LHS.release();
4430 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004431 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004432 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004433 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004434}
4435
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004436// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004437// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004438// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4439// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4440// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004441Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004442Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004443 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004444
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004445 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4446 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4447 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4448 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4449 return Compatible;
4450 }
4451
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004452 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004453 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4454 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004455
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004456 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004457 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4458 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004459
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004460 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004461
4462 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4463 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4464 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004465 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004466 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004467 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004468
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004469 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4470 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004471 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004472 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004473 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004474 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004475
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004476 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004477 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4478 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004479 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004480
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004481 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004482 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004483 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004484
4485 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004486 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4487 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004488 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004489 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004490 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004491 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4492 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4493 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4494 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4495 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4496 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004497 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004498 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004499 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004500 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004501
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004502 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004503 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004504 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004505 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004506
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004507 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4508 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4509 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4510 // warning can be disabled.
4511 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4512 return ConvTy;
4513 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4514 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004515
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004516 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4517 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4518 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4519 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4520 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4521 do {
4522 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4523 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004524
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004525 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4526 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4527 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004528
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004529 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004530 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004531 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004532
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004533 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004534 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004535 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004536 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004537}
4538
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004539/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4540/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4541/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4542// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004543Sema::AssignConvertType
4544Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004545 QualType rhsType) {
4546 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004547
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004548 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004549 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4550 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004551
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004552 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4553 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4554 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004555
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004556 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004557
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004558 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004559 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004560 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004561
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004562 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4563 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4564 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4565 }
4566 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004567 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004568 return ConvTy;
4569}
4570
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004571/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4572/// for assignment compatibility.
4573Sema::AssignConvertType
4574Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004575 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4576 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004577 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4578 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004579 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004580 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004581 }
4582 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4583 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004584 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4585 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004586 return IncompatiblePointer;
4587 return Compatible;
4588 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004589 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004590 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004591 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004592 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4593 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4594 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4595 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4596 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4597 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004598
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004599 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4600 return Compatible;
4601 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4602 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004603 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004604}
4605
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004606/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4607/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004608/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4609///
4610/// int a, *pint;
4611/// short *pshort;
4612/// struct foo *pfoo;
4613///
4614/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4615/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4616/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4617/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4618///
4619/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004620/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004621///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004622Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004623Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004624 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4625 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004626 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4627 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004628
4629 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004630 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004631
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004632 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4633 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4634 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4635 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4636 return Compatible;
4637 }
4638
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004639 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4640 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4641 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4642 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4643 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4644 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4645 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004646 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004647 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004648 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004649 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004650 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004651 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4652 // to the same ExtVector type.
4653 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4654 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4655 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4656 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4657 return Compatible;
4658 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004659
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004660 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004661 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004662 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004663 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004664 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4665 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004666 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004667 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004668 }
4669 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004670 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004671
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004672 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004673 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004674
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004675 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004676 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004677 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004678
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004679 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004680 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004681
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004682 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004683 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004684 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4685 return Compatible;
4686 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004687 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004688 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4689 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004690 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004691
4692 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004693 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004694 return Compatible;
4695 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004696 return Incompatible;
4697 }
4698
4699 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4700 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004701 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004702
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004703 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004704 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004705 return Compatible;
4706
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004707 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4708 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004709
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004710 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004711 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004712 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004713 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004714 return Incompatible;
4715 }
4716
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004717 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4718 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4719 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004720
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004721 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004722 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004723 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4724 return Compatible;
4725 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004726 }
4727 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004728 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004729 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004730 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004731 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4732 return Compatible;
4733 }
4734 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4735 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4736 return Compatible;
4737 return Incompatible;
4738 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004739 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004740 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004741 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4742 return Compatible;
4743
4744 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004745 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004746
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004747 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004748 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004749
4750 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004751 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004752 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004753 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004754 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004755 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4756 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4757 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4758 return Compatible;
4759
4760 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4761 return PointerToInt;
4762
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004763 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004764 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004765 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4766 return Compatible;
4767 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004768 }
4769 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004770 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004771 return Compatible;
4772 return Incompatible;
4773 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004774
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004775 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004776 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004777 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004778 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004779 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004780}
4781
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004782/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4783/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004784static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004785 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4786 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4787 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004788 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004789 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004790 SourceLocation());
4791 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4792 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4793
4794 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4795 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004796 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004797 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004798 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004799}
4800
4801Sema::AssignConvertType
4802Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4803 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4804
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004805 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004806 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4807 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004808 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004809 return Incompatible;
4810
4811 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4812 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4813 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4814 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004815 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4816 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004817 it != itend; ++it) {
4818 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4819 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4820 // 1) void pointer
4821 // 2) null pointer constant
4822 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004823 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004824 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004825 InitField = *it;
4826 break;
4827 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004828
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004829 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004830 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004831 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004832 InitField = *it;
4833 break;
4834 }
4835 }
4836
4837 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4838 == Compatible) {
4839 InitField = *it;
4840 break;
4841 }
4842 }
4843
4844 if (!InitField)
4845 return Incompatible;
4846
4847 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4848 return Compatible;
4849}
4850
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004851Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004852Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004853 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4854 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4855 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4856 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4857 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004858 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004859 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004860 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004861 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004862 }
4863
4864 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4865 // structures.
4866 }
4867
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004868 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4869 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004870 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4871 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004872 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004873 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004874 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004875 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004876 return Compatible;
4877 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004878
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004879 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004880 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004881 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004882 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004883 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004884 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004885 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004886 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004887
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004888 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4889 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004890
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004891 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4892 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004893 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4894 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4895 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4896 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004897 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004898 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4899 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004900 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004901}
4902
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004903QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004904 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004905 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004906 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004907 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004908}
4909
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004910QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004911 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004912 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004913 QualType lhsType =
4914 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4915 QualType rhsType =
4916 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004917
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004918 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004919 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004920 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004921
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004922 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4923 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004924 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4925 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004926 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4927 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004928 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004929 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004930 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4931 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4932 return lhsType;
4933 }
4934
4935 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4936 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004937 }
4938 }
4939 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004940
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004941 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4942 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4943 bool swapped = false;
4944 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4945 swapped = true;
4946 std::swap(rex, lex);
4947 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4948 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004949
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004950 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004951 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004952 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4953 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4954 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004955 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004956 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4957 return lhsType;
4958 }
4959 }
4960 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4961 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4962 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004963 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004964 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4965 return lhsType;
4966 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004967 }
4968 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004969
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004970 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004971 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004972 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004973 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004974 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004975}
4976
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004977QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4978 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004979 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004980 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004981
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004982 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004983
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004984 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4985 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4986 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004987
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004988 // Check for division by zero.
4989 if (isDiv &&
4990 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004991 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004992 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004993
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004994 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004995}
4996
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004997QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004998 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004999 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5000 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5001 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5002 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5003 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005004
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005005 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005006
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005007 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5008 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005009
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005010 // Check for remainder by zero.
5011 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005012 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5013 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005014
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005015 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005016}
5017
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005018QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005019 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005020 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5021 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5022 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5023 return compType;
5024 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005025
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005026 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005027
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005028 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005029 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5030 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5031 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005032 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005033 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005034
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005035 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5036 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005037 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005038 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5039
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005040 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005041
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005042 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005043 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005044
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005045 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5046 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005047 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5048 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005049 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005050 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005051 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005052
5053 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5054 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5055 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005056 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005057 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5058 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5059 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5060 return QualType();
5061 }
5062
5063 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5064 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5065 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005066 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005067 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005068 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005069 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005070 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5071 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005072 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5073 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005074 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005075 return QualType();
5076 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005077 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005078 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005079 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5080 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5081 return QualType();
5082 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005083
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005084 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005085 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5086 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5087 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5088 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5089 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005090 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5092 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005093 return PExp->getType();
5094 }
5095 }
5096
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005097 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005098}
5099
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005100// C99 6.5.6
5101QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005102 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5103 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5104 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5105 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5106 return compType;
5107 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005108
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005109 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005110
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005111 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005113 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005114 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5115 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005116 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005117 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005118 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005119
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005120 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005121 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005122 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005123
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005124 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005125
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005126 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5127 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5128 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5129 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5130 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5131 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5132 return QualType();
5133 }
5134
5135 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5136 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5137 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5138 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5139 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005140 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005141 return QualType();
5142 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005143
5144 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5145 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5146 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005147 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005148 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005149 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005150 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005151 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005152
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005153 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005154 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005155 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5156 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5157 return QualType();
5158 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005159
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005160 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005161 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5162 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5163 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5164 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5165 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5166 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005167 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005168 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5169
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005170 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005171 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005172 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005173
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005174 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005175 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005176 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005177
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005178 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5179 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5180 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5181 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5182 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5183 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5184 return QualType();
5185 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005186
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005187 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5188 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5189 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5190 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005191 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005192 return QualType();
5193 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005194
5195 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5196 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5197 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5198 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5199 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005200 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5201 << rex->getSourceRange()
5202 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005203 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005204
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005205 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5206 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5207 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5208 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5209 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5210 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5211 return QualType();
5212 }
5213 } else {
5214 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5215 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5216 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5217 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5218 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5219 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5220 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5221 return QualType();
5222 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005223 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005224
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005225 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5226 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5227 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5228 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5229 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005230 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005231 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005232
5233 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005234 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5235 }
5236 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005237
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005238 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005239}
5240
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005241// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005242QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005243 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005244 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5245 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005246 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005247
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005248 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5249 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5250 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5251
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005252 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5253 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005254 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5255 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5256 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5257 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5258 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005259 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005260 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005261 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005262
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005263 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005264
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005265 // Sanity-check shift operands
5266 llvm::APSInt Right;
5267 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005268 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5269 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005270 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005271 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5272 else {
5273 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5274 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5275 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5276 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5277 }
5278 }
5279
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005280 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005281 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005282}
5283
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005284// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005285QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005286 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5287 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5288
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005289 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005290 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005291 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005292
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005293 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005294 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5295 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5296 else {
5297 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5298 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5299 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005300 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5301 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005302
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005303 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5304 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005305 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5306 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5307 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005308 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005309 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005310 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5311 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5312 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5313 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005314 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5315 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005316 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005317
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005318 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5319 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5320 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5321 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005322
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005323 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5324 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005325 Expr *literalString = 0;
5326 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005327 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005328 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005329 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005330 literalString = lex;
5331 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005332 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5333 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005334 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005335 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005336 literalString = rex;
5337 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5338 }
5339
5340 if (literalString) {
5341 std::string resultComparison;
5342 switch (Opc) {
5343 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5344 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5345 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5346 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5347 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5348 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5349 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5350 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005351
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005352 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5353 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5354 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005355 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005356 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005357 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005358
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005359 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005360 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005361
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005362 if (isRelational) {
5363 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005364 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005365 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005366 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005367 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005368 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005369
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005370 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005371 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005372 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005373
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005374 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005375 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005376 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005377 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005378
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005379 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5380 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5381 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005382 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005383 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005384 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005385 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005386 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005387
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005388 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005389 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5390 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005391 if (!isRelational &&
5392 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5393 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5394 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5395 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5396 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5397 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5398 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5399 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5400 return ResultTy;
5401 }
5402 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005403 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5404 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5405 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5406 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5407 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5408 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005409 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005410 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005411 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005412 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005413 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005414 if (T.isNull()) {
5415 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5416 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5417 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005418 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005419 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005420 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005421 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005422 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005423 }
5424
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005425 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5426 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005427 return ResultTy;
5428 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005429 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5430 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5431 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5432 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5433 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5434 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5435 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5436 }
5437 } else if (!isRelational &&
5438 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5439 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5440 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5441 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5442 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5443 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5444 }
5445 } else {
5446 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005447 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005448 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005449 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005450 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005451 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005452 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005453 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005454
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005455 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005456 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005457 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005458 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005459 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5460 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005461 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005462 return ResultTy;
5463 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005464 if (LHSIsNull &&
5465 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5466 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005467 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005468 return ResultTy;
5469 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005470
5471 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005472 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005473 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5474 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005475 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5476 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5477 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5478 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5479 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5480 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5481 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5482 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005483 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005484 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005485 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005486 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005487 if (T.isNull()) {
5488 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005489 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005490 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005491 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005492 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005493 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005494 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005495 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005496 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005497
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005498 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5499 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005500 return ResultTy;
5501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005502
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005503 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005504 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5505 return ResultTy;
5506 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005507
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005508 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005509 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005510 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5511 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005512
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005513 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005514 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005515 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005516 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005517 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005518 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005519 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005520 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005521 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005522 if (!isRelational
5523 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5524 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005525 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005526 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005527 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005528 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005529 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5530 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5531 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005532 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005533 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005534 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005535 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005536
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005537 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005538 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005539 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5540 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005541 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005542 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005543 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005544 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005545
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005546 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5547 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005548 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005549 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005550 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005551 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005552 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005553 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005554 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005555 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005556 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5557 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005558 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005559 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005560 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005561 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005562 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005563 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5564 if (RHSIsNull) {
5565 if (isRelational)
5566 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5567 } else if (isRelational)
5568 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5569 else
5570 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005571
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005572 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005573 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005574 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005575 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005576 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005577 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005578 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005579 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005580 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5581 if (LHSIsNull) {
5582 if (isRelational)
5583 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5584 } else if (isRelational)
5585 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5586 else
5587 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005588
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005589 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005590 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005591 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005592 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005593 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005594 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005595 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005596 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005597 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5598 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005599 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005600 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005601 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005602 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5603 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005604 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005605 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005606 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005607 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005608}
5609
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005610/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005611/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005612/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5613/// types.
5614QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005615 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005616 bool isRelational) {
5617 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5618 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005619 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005620 if (vType.isNull())
5621 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005622
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005623 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5624 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005625
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005626 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5627 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5628 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5629 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5630 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5631 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5632 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005633 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005634 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005635
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005636 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5637 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5638 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005639 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005640 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005641
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005642 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5643 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5644 // elements for floating point vectors.
5645 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5646 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005647
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005648 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005649 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005650 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005651 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005652 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005653 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5654
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005655 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005656 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005657 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5658}
5659
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005660inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005661 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005662 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005663 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005664
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005665 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005666
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005667 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005668 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005669 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005670}
5671
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005672inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005673 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005674 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5675 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5676 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005677
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005678 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5679 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005680
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005681 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005682 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005683
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005684 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5685 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5686 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5687 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5688 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5689 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5690 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005691
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005692 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005693 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005694 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005695
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005696 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5697 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5698 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5699 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005700
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005701 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005702 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005703 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005704
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005705 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5706 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5707 // The result is a bool.
5708 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005709}
5710
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005711/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5712/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5713/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5714///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005715static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005716 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5717 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5718 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5719 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005720 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005721 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5722 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5723 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5724 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005725 }
5726 }
5727 return false;
5728}
5729
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005730/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5731/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5732static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005733 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005734 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005735 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005736 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5737 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005738 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5739 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005740
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005741 unsigned Diag = 0;
5742 bool NeedType = false;
5743 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005744 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005745 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005746 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5747 NeedType = true;
5748 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005749 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005750 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5751 NeedType = true;
5752 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005753 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005754 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5755 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005756 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5757 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005758 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005759 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5760 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005761 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5762 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005763 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5764 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005765 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005766 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005767 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005768 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005769 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5770 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005771 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005772 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5773 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005774 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5775 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5776 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005777 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5778 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5779 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005780 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5781 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5782 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005783 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005784
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005785 SourceRange Assign;
5786 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5787 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005788 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005789 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005790 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005791 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005792 return true;
5793}
5794
5795
5796
5797// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005798QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5799 SourceLocation Loc,
5800 QualType CompoundType) {
5801 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5802 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005803 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005804
5805 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5806 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005807
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005808 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005809 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005810 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005811 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005812 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5813 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5814 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005815 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005816 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005817 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005818 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005819
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005820 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5821 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5822 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005823 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005824 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5825 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5826 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5827 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5828 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005829 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005830 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005831 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5832 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5833 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005834 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5835 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005836 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5837 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5838 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005839 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005840 }
5841 } else {
5842 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005843 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005844 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005845
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005846 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005847 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005848 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005849
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005850 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5851 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005852 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005853 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5854 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005855 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005856 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005857 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005858}
5859
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005860// C99 6.5.17
5861QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005862 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005863 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5864 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5865 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005866
5867 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5868 // incomplete in C++).
5869
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005870 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005871}
5872
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005873/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5874/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005875QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005876 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005877 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5878 return Context.DependentTy;
5879
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005880 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5881 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005882
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005883 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5884 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5885 if (!isInc) {
5886 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5887 return QualType();
5888 }
5889 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5890 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5891 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005892 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005893 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5894 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005895
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005896 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005897 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005898 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5899 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5900 << Op->getSourceRange();
5901 return QualType();
5902 }
5903
5904 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005905 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005906 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005907 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5908 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5909 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5910 return QualType();
5911 }
5912
5913 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005914 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005915 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005916 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005917 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005918 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005919 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005920 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005921 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005922 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5923 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5924 return QualType();
5925 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005926 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005927 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5928 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005929 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005930 } else {
5931 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005932 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005933 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005934 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005935 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005936 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005937 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005938 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005939 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5940 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5941 // operand.
5942 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5943 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005944}
5945
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005946/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005947/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005948/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5949/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5950/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5951/// - &(x) => x
5952/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5953/// - &s.xx => s
5954/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5955/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5956/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5957/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005958static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005959 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005960 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005961 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005962 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005963 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5964 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5965 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005966 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005967 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005968 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005969 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005970 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005971 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5972 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005973 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5974 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5975 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5976 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5977 }
5978 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005979 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005980 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5981 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005982
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005983 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005984 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5985 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5986 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5987 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5988 default:
5989 return 0;
5990 }
5991 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005992 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005993 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005994 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005995 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5996 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005997 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005998 default:
5999 return 0;
6000 }
6001}
6002
6003/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006004/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006005/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006006/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006007/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006008/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006009/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006010QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006011 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6012 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6013
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006014 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6015 return Context.DependentTy;
6016
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006017 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6018 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6019 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6020 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6021 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6022 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6023 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6024 }
6025 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6026 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6027 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006028 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006029 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006030
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006031 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6032 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6033 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6034 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6035 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6036 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6037 // branch of the if, below.
6038 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6039 << dcl;
6040 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6041
6042 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6043 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6044 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6045 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006046 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6047 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6048 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6049 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6050 if (isSFINAEContext())
6051 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006052 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006053 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006054 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006055 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006056 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006057 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6058 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006059 return QualType();
6060 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006061 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006062 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6063 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6064 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006065 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006066 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006067 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006068 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006069 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006070 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006071 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6072 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6073 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6074 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6075 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006076 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6077 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006078 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6079 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006080 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6081 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006082 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006083 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006084 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6085 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006086 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006087 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6088 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006089 return QualType();
6090 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006091 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006092 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006093 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006094 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006095 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6096 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006097 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006098 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006099 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6100 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006101 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006102 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6103 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6104 return QualType();
6105 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006106
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006107 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6108 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006109 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006110 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006111 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006112 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006113 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006114 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6115 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006116 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6117 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6118 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006119 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006120 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006121
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006122 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6123 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6124 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6125 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6126 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6127 }
6128
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006129 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006130 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006131}
6132
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006133QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006134 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6135 return Context.DependentTy;
6136
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006137 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6138 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006139
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006140 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6141 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6142 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6143 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006144 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006145 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006146
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006147 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006148 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006149
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006150 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006151 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006152 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006153}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006154
6155static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6156 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6157 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6158 switch (Kind) {
6159 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006160 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6161 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006162 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6163 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6164 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6165 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6166 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6167 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6168 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6169 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6170 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6171 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6172 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6173 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6174 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6175 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6176 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6177 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6178 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6179 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6180 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6181 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6182 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6183 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6184 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6185 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6186 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6187 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6188 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6189 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6190 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6191 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6192 }
6193 return Opc;
6194}
6195
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006196static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6197 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6198 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6199 switch (Kind) {
6200 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6201 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6202 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6203 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6204 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6205 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6206 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6207 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6208 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006209 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6210 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006211 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006212 }
6213 return Opc;
6214}
6215
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006216/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6217/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6218/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006219Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6220 unsigned Op,
6221 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006222 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006223 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006224 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6225 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6226 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006227
6228 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006229 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6230 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6231 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006232 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6233 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6234 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6235 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6236 break;
6237 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006238 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006239 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6240 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006241 break;
6242 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6243 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6244 break;
6245 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6246 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6247 break;
6248 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6249 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6250 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006251 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006252 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6253 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6254 break;
6255 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6256 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6257 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6258 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006259 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006260 break;
6261 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6262 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006263 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006264 break;
6265 case BinaryOperator::And:
6266 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6267 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6268 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6269 break;
6270 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6271 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6272 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6273 break;
6274 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6275 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006276 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6277 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006278 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6279 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6280 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006281 break;
6282 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006283 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6284 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6285 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6286 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006287 break;
6288 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006289 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6290 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6291 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006292 break;
6293 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006294 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6295 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6296 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006297 break;
6298 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6299 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006300 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6301 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6302 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6303 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006304 break;
6305 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6306 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6307 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006308 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6309 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6310 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6311 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006312 break;
6313 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6314 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6315 break;
6316 }
6317 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006318 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006319 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006320 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6321 else
6322 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006323 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6324 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006325}
6326
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006327/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6328/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006329static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6330 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006331 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6332 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6333 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006334 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006335 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6336
6337 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6338 return;
6339
6340 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6341 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6342 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006343 return;
6344 }
6345
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006346 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6347 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006348 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006349
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006350 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006351 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006352
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006353 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6354 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6355 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6356 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006357 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006358 return;
6359 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006360
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006361 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006362 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6363 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006364}
6365
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006366/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6367/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6368/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6369/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006370static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6371 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006372 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6373 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6374 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6375 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006376 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006377 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006378 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6379
6380 // Subs are not binary operators.
6381 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6382 return;
6383
6384 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6385 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006386 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6387 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006388 return;
6389
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006390 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006391 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006392 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006393 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6394 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006395 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006396 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006397 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6398 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6399 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6400 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006401 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006402 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006403 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006404 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6405 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006406 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006407 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006408 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6409 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6410 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6411 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006412}
6413
6414/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6415/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6416/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6417static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6418 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006419 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006420 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6421}
6422
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006423// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006424Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6425 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6426 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006427 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006428 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006429
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006430 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6431 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006432
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006433 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6434 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6435
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006436 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6437}
6438
6439Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6440 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6441 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006442 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006443 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006444 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6445 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6446 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6447 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6448 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006449 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006450 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006451 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6452 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6453 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006454
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006455 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6456 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006457 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006458 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006459
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006460 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006461 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006462}
6463
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006464Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006465 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006466 ExprArg InputArg) {
6467 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006468
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006469 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006470 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006471 QualType resultType;
6472 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006473 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6474 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6475 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006476
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006477 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6478 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006479 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6480 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006481 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006482 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006483 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6484 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6485 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006486 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006487 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006488 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006489 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006490 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006491 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006492 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006493 break;
6494 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6495 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006496 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6497 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006498 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6499 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006500 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6501 break;
6502 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6503 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6504 break;
6505 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6506 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6507 resultType->isPointerType())
6508 break;
6509
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006510 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6511 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006512 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006513 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6514 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006515 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6516 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006517 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6518 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6519 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006520 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006521 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006522 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006523 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6524 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006525 break;
6526 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006527 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006528 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006529 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006530 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6531 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006532 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006533 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6534 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006535 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006536 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6537 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006538 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006539 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006540 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006541 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006542 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006543 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006544 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006545 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006546 }
6547 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006548 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006549
6550 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006551 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006552}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006553
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006554Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6555 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6556 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006557 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006558 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6559 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006560 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6561 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6562 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6563 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006564 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006565 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006566 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6567 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6568 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006569
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006570 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6571 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006572
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006573 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6574}
6575
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006576// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6577Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6578 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6579 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6580}
6581
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006582/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006583Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6584 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6585 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006586 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006587 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006588
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006589 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6590 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006591 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006592 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006593
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006594 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006595 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6596 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006597}
6598
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006599Sema::OwningExprResult
6600Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6601 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6602 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006603 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6604 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6605
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006606 bool isFileScope
6607 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006608 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006609 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006610
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006611 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6612 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6613 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006614
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006615 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6616 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6617 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006618
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006619 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6620 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6621 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6622 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6623 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006624
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006625 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006626 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006627 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006628
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006629 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6630 // expressions are not lvalues.
6631
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006632 substmt.release();
6633 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006634}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006635
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006636Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6637 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006638 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6639 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006640 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6641 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006642 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006643 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006644
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006645 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6646 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6647 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006648 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006649 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6650 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6651
6652 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6653 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6654 if (!Dependent
6655 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6656 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6657 << TypeRange))
6658 return ExprError();
6659
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006660 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6661 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006662 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6663 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006664 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006665 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6666 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006667
6668 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6669 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6670 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6671 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6672 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6673 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6674 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6675 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6676 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6677 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6678 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6679 if(!AT)
6680 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6681 << CurrentType);
6682 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6683 } else
6684 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6685
6686 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6687 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6688 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6689 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6690 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6691 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6692 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6693 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6694
6695 // Record this array index.
6696 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6697 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6698 continue;
6699 }
6700
6701 // Offset of a field.
6702 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6703 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6704 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6705 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6706 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6707 continue;
6708 }
6709
6710 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6711 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6712 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6713 return ExprError();
6714
6715 // Look for the designated field.
6716 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6717 if (!RC)
6718 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6719 << CurrentType);
6720 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6721
6722 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6723 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6724 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6725 // (clause 9).
6726 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6727 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6728 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6729 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6730 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6731 << CurrentType))
6732 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6733 }
6734
6735 // Look for the field.
6736 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6737 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6738 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6739 if (!MemberDecl)
6740 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6741 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6742 OC.LocEnd));
6743
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006744 // C99 7.17p3:
6745 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6746 //
6747 // We diagnose this as an error.
6748 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6749 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6750 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6751 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6752 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6753 return ExprError();
6754 }
6755
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006756 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6757 // the base class indirections.
6758 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6759 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6760 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6761 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6762 Paths)) {
6763 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6764 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6765 B != BEnd; ++B)
6766 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6767 }
6768
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006769 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006770 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006771 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6772 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6773 unsigned n = Path.size();
6774 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6775 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6776 } else {
6777 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6778 }
6779 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6780 }
6781
6782 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6783 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6784 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6785}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006786
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006787Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6788 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6789 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6790 TypeTy *argty,
6791 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6792 unsigned NumComponents,
6793 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6794
6795 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6796 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6797 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6798 return ExprError();
6799
6800 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6801 if (!ArgTInfo)
6802 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6803
6804 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6805 RPLoc);
6806 }
6807
6808 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6809 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6810
6811 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6812
6813 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6814 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6815 // a struct/union/class.
6816 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6817 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6818
6819 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6820 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6821
6822 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6823 // the offsetof designators.
6824 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6825 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6826 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6827 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6828
6829 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6830 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6831 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6832 // a system header!
6833 if (NumComponents != 1)
6834 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6835 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6836
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006837 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006838 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006839
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006840 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6841 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6842 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006843
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006844 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6845 // leaks like a sieve.
6846 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6847 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6848 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6849 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6850 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6851 if (!AT) {
6852 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006853 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006854 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006855 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006856
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006857 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006858
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006859 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6860 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006861 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006862
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006863 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6864 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006865 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006866 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006867 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006868 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006869 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6870
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006871 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6872 OC.LocEnd);
6873 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006874 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006875
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006876 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006877 if (!RC) {
6878 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006879 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006880 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006881 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006882
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006883 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6884 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006885 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006886 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6887 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6888 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006889 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6890 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006891 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006892 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006893
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006894 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6895 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006896
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006897 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006898 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006899 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006900 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006901 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6902
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006903 // C99 7.17p3:
6904 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6905 //
6906 // We diagnose this as an error.
6907 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6908 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6909 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6910 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6911 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6912 return ExprError();
6913 }
6914
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006915 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6916 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006917 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006918 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006919 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006920 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006921 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6922 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006923 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6924 // doesn't matter here.
6925 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006926 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006927 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006928 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006929 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006930
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006931 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6932 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006933}
6934
6935
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006936Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6937 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6938 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006939 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6940 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6941 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006942
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006943 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006944
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006945 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6946 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6947 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6948 return ExprError();
6949 }
6950
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006951 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6952 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006953}
6954
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006955Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6956 ExprArg cond,
6957 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6958 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6959 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6960 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6961 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006962
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006963 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6964
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006965 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006966 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006967 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006968 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006969 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006970 } else {
6971 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6972 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6973 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6974 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006975 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6976 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6977 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006978
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006979 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6980 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006981 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6982 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006983 }
6984
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006985 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6986 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006987 resType, RPLoc,
6988 resType->isDependentType(),
6989 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006990}
6991
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006992//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6993// Clang Extensions.
6994//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6995
6996/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006997void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006998 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6999 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7000 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7001 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007002}
7003
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007004void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007005 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007006 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007007
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007008 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
7009 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007010 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007011 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
7012
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00007013 if (T->isArrayType()) {
7014 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7015 diag::err_block_returns_array);
7016 return;
7017 }
7018
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007019 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
7020 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007021 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
7022 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007023
7024 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
7025 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007026 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007027 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007028 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007029 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007030 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7031 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007032 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007033
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007034 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007035 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007036 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7037 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7038 return;
7039 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007040
7041 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007042 return;
7043 }
7044
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007045 // Analyze arguments to block.
7046 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
7047 "Not a function declarator!");
7048 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007049
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007050 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
7051 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007052
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007053 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
7054 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
7055 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
7056 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00007057 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
7058 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007059 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007060 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007061 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007062 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
7063 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
7064 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7065 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7066 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7067 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7068 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
7069 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
7070 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007071 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007072 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00007073 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007074 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00007075 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007076 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007077
7078 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7079 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7080
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007081 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007082 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7083 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7084
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007085 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007086 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7087 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7088 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7089
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007090 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007091 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007092 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007093
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007094 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007095 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007096 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007097 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007098 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007099 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7100 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007101
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007102 // Analyze the return type.
7103 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007104 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007105
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007106 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007107 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007108 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7109 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7110 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007111 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007112}
7113
7114/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7115/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7116void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007117 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007118 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007119 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007120 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007121}
7122
7123/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7124/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007125Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7126 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007127 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7128 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7129 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007130
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007131 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007132
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007133 PopDeclContext();
7134
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007135 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007136 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7137 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007138
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007139 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7140 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7141 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007142
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007143 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007144 QualType BlockTy;
7145 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007146 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007147 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007148 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007149 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007150 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007151 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007152
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007153 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007154 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007155 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007156
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007157 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007158 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007159 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007160
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007161 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007162
7163 bool Good = true;
7164 // Check goto/label use.
7165 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7166 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7167 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7168
7169 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7170 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7171 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7172 continue;
7173
7174 // Emit error.
7175 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7176 Good = false;
7177 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007178 if (!Good) {
7179 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007180 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007181 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007182
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007183 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007184 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7185 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7186 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007187
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007188 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7189 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007190 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007191 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007192}
7193
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007194Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7195 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7196 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007197 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007198 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7199 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007200
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007201 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007202
7203 // Get the va_list type
7204 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007205 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7206 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7207 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7208 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007209 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007210 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7211 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7212 } else {
7213 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7214 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007215 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007216 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007217 return ExprError();
7218 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007219
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007220 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7221 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007222 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7223 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007224 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007225 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007226
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007227 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007228 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007229
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007230 expr.release();
7231 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7232 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007233}
7234
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007235Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007236 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7237 // pointers on the target.
7238 QualType Ty;
7239 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7240 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7241 else
7242 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7243
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007244 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007245}
7246
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007247static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007248 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007249 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7250 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007251
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007252 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7253 if (!PT)
7254 return;
7255
7256 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7257 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7258 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7259 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7260 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7261 return;
7262 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007263
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007264 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7265 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7266 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7267 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007268
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007269 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007270}
7271
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007272bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7273 SourceLocation Loc,
7274 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007275 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7276 bool *Complained) {
7277 if (Complained)
7278 *Complained = false;
7279
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007280 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7281 bool isInvalid = false;
7282 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007283 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007284
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007285 switch (ConvTy) {
7286 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7287 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007288 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007289 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7290 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007291 case IntToPointer:
7292 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7293 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007294 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007295 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007296 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7297 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007298 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7299 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7300 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007301 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7302 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7303 break;
7304 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007305 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7306 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7307 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7308 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7309 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7310 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7311 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7312 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7313 // C++ semantics.
7314 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7315 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7316 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007317 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7318 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007319 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007320 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007321 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007322 case IntToBlockPointer:
7323 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7324 break;
7325 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007326 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007327 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007328 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007329 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007330 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7331 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7332 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007333 case IncompatibleVectors:
7334 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7335 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007336 case Incompatible:
7337 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7338 isInvalid = true;
7339 break;
7340 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007341
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007342 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7343 switch (Action) {
7344 case AA_Assigning:
7345 case AA_Initializing:
7346 // The destination type comes first.
7347 FirstType = DstType;
7348 SecondType = SrcType;
7349 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007350
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007351 case AA_Returning:
7352 case AA_Passing:
7353 case AA_Converting:
7354 case AA_Sending:
7355 case AA_Casting:
7356 // The source type comes first.
7357 FirstType = SrcType;
7358 SecondType = DstType;
7359 break;
7360 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007361
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007362 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007363 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007364 if (Complained)
7365 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007366 return isInvalid;
7367}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007368
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007369bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007370 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7371 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7372 if (Result)
7373 *Result = ICEResult;
7374 return false;
7375 }
7376
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007377 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7378
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007379 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007380 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7381 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7382
7383 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7384 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7385 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7386 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7387 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7388 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7389 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007390
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007391 return true;
7392 }
7393
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007394 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7395 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007396
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007397 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7398 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7399 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007400
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007401 if (Result)
7402 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7403 return false;
7404}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007405
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007406void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007407Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007408 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7409 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007410}
7411
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007412void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007413Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7414 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7415 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7416 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007417
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007418 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7419 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7420 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7421 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7422 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007423 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007424 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7425 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7426 I != IEnd; ++I)
7427 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7428 }
7429
7430 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7431 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7432 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7433 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7434 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7435 I != IEnd; ++I)
7436 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7437 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007438 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007439
7440 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7441 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7442 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7443 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007444 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007445 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7446 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7447 ExprTemporaries.end());
7448
7449 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7450 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007451}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007452
7453/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7454///
7455/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7456/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7457/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7458/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7459///
7460/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7461///
7462/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7463void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7464 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007465
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007466 if (D->isUsed())
7467 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007468
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007469 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7470 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7471 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7472 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007473 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007474 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007475 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007476 return;
7477 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007478
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007479 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7480 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007481
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007482 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7483 // an instantiation.
7484 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7485 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007486
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007487 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007488 case Unevaluated:
7489 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7490 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007491
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007492 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7493 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7494 // "used"; handle this below.
7495 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007496
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007497 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7498 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7499 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7500 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007501 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007502 return;
7503 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007504
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007505 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007506 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007507 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007508 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7509 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7510 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007511 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007512 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007513 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7514 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7515 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007516
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007517 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007518 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7519 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7520 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007521 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7522 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007523 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7524 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7525 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7526 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007527 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007528 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7529 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007530 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007531 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007532 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007533 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007534 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007535 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7536 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7537 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7538 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7539 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007540 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007541 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007542 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007543 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007544 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7545 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7546 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007547 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007548 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007549 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7550 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007551
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007552 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7553 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7554 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7555 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7556 Loc));
7557 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007558 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007559 Loc));
7560 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007561 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007562
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007563 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007564 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007565
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007566 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007567 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007568
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007569 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007570 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007571 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007572 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7573 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7574 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7575 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7576 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7577 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7578 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7579 }
7580 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007581
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007582 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007583
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007584 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007585 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007586 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007587}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007588
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007589namespace {
7590 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
7591 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
7592 // of when we're entering
7593 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7594 Sema &S;
7595 SourceLocation Loc;
7596
7597 public:
7598 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
7599
7600 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
7601
7602 bool VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7603 bool VisitRecordType(RecordType *T);
7604 };
7605}
7606
7607bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
7608 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7609 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7610 }
7611
7612 return Inherited::VisitTemplateArgument(Arg);
7613}
7614
7615bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitRecordType(RecordType *T) {
7616 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7617 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7618 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7619 return VisitTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7620 Args.flat_size());
7621 }
7622
7623 return false;
7624}
7625
7626void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7627 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
7628 Marker.Visit(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
7629}
7630
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007631/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7632/// of the program being compiled.
7633///
7634/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007635/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007636/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7637/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7638/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7639/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007640/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007641/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007642///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007643/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7644/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7645/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7646/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007647bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007648 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7649 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7650 case Unevaluated:
7651 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7652 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007653
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007654 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7655 Diag(Loc, PD);
7656 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007657
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007658 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7659 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7660 break;
7661 }
7662
7663 return false;
7664}
7665
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007666bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7667 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7668 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7669 return false;
7670
7671 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7672 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7673 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7674 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007675
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007676 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007677 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007678 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7679 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007680 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007681 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7682 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7683 return true;
7684
7685 return false;
7686}
7687
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007688// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7689// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7690void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7691 SourceLocation Loc;
7692
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007693 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7694
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007695 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7696 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7697 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7698 return;
7699
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007700 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7701 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7702 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7703 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7704
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007705 // self = [<foo> init...]
7706 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7707 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7708 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7709
7710 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7711 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7712 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7713 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7714 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007715
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007716 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7717 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7718 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7719 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7720 return;
7721
7722 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7723 } else {
7724 // Not an assignment.
7725 return;
7726 }
7727
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007728 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007729 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007730
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007731 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007732 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007733 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007734 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7735 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7736 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007737}
7738
7739bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7740 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7741
7742 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007743 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007744
7745 QualType T = E->getType();
7746
7747 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7748 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7749 return true;
7750 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7751 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7752 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7753 return true;
7754 }
7755 }
7756
7757 return false;
7758}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007759
7760Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7761 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007762 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7763 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007764 return ExprError();
7765
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007766 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7767 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7768 return ExprError();
7769 }
7770
7771 return Owned(Sub);
7772}